ext2: fix missing percpu_counter_inc
[linux/fpc-iii.git] / include / net / cfg80211.h
blob68782ba8b6e8d75ef7a20403b6f47786cd4f80be
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2019 Intel Corporation
13 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
14 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
15 #include <linux/list.h>
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/netlink.h>
18 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
19 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
20 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
22 #include <linux/net.h>
23 #include <net/regulatory.h>
25 /**
26 * DOC: Introduction
28 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
29 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
30 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
31 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
32 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
33 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
35 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
36 * use restrictions.
40 /**
41 * DOC: Device registration
43 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
44 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
45 * described below.
47 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
48 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
49 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
50 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
51 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
52 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
53 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
54 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
55 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
57 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
58 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
59 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
62 struct wiphy;
65 * wireless hardware capability structures
68 /**
69 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
71 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
73 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
74 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
75 * sending probe requests or beaconing.
76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
78 * is not permitted.
79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
80 * is not permitted.
81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
83 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
84 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
85 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
86 * restrictions.
87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
88 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91 * restrictions.
92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
93 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
94 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
95 * on this channel.
96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
97 * on this channel.
100 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
101 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0,
102 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1,
103 /* hole at 1<<2 */
104 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3,
105 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4,
106 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5,
107 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6,
108 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7,
109 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8,
110 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9,
111 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10,
112 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11,
113 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12,
116 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
117 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
119 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000
120 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000)
123 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
125 * This structure describes a single channel for use
126 * with cfg80211.
128 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
129 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
130 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
131 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
132 * code to support devices with additional restrictions
133 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
134 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
135 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
136 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
137 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
138 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
139 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
140 * @orig_mag: internal use
141 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
142 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
143 * on this channel.
144 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
145 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
147 struct ieee80211_channel {
148 enum nl80211_band band;
149 u32 center_freq;
150 u16 hw_value;
151 u32 flags;
152 int max_antenna_gain;
153 int max_power;
154 int max_reg_power;
155 bool beacon_found;
156 u32 orig_flags;
157 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
158 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
159 unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
160 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
164 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
166 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
167 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
168 * different bands/PHY modes.
170 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
171 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
172 * with CCK rates.
173 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
174 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
175 * core code when registering the wiphy.
176 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
177 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
178 * core code when registering the wiphy.
179 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
180 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
181 * core code when registering the wiphy.
182 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
183 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
184 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
186 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
187 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0,
188 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1,
189 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2,
190 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3,
191 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4,
192 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5,
193 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6,
197 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
199 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
200 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
201 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
202 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
203 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
205 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
206 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
207 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
208 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
209 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
210 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
214 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
216 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
217 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
218 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
220 enum ieee80211_privacy {
221 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
222 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
223 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
226 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \
227 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
230 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
232 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
233 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
234 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
235 * passed around.
237 * @flags: rate-specific flags
238 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
239 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
240 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
241 * short preamble is used
243 struct ieee80211_rate {
244 u32 flags;
245 u16 bitrate;
246 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
250 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
252 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
253 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
254 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
256 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
257 bool enable;
258 u8 min_offset;
259 u8 max_offset;
263 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
265 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
266 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
268 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
269 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
270 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
271 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
272 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
274 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
275 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
276 bool ht_supported;
277 u8 ampdu_factor;
278 u8 ampdu_density;
279 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
283 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
285 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
286 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
288 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
289 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
290 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
292 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
293 bool vht_supported;
294 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
295 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
298 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25
301 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
303 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
304 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
306 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
307 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
308 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
309 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
311 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
312 bool has_he;
313 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
314 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
315 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
319 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data
321 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
322 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the
323 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
325 * @types_mask: interface types mask
326 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
328 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
329 u16 types_mask;
330 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
334 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
336 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
337 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
338 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
339 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
340 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
341 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
342 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
343 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
344 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
345 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
346 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
347 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
348 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
349 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
350 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
351 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
352 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
354 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
355 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4,
356 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5,
357 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6,
358 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7,
359 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8,
360 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9,
361 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10,
362 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11,
363 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12,
364 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13,
365 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14,
366 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15,
370 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
372 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
373 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
375 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
376 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
377 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
378 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
379 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
380 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
382 struct ieee80211_edmg {
383 u8 channels;
384 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
388 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
390 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
391 * is able to operate in.
393 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate in
394 * in this band.
395 * @band: the band this structure represents
396 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
397 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
398 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
399 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
400 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
401 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
402 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
403 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
404 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
405 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in
406 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
407 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
408 * iftype_data).
410 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
411 struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
412 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
413 enum nl80211_band band;
414 int n_channels;
415 int n_bitrates;
416 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
417 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
418 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
419 u16 n_iftype_data;
420 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
424 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
425 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
426 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
428 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
430 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
431 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
432 u8 iftype)
434 int i;
436 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
437 return NULL;
439 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) {
440 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
441 &sband->iftype_data[i];
443 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
444 return data;
447 return NULL;
451 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
452 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
453 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
455 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
457 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
458 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
459 u8 iftype)
461 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
462 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
464 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
465 return &data->he_cap;
467 return NULL;
471 * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA
472 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
474 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
476 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
477 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband)
479 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION);
483 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
485 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
487 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
488 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
489 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
491 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
492 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
493 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
494 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
495 * without affecting other devices.
497 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
498 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
499 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
501 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
502 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
503 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
504 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
507 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
511 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
515 * DOC: Actions and configuration
517 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
518 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
519 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
520 * operations use are described separately.
522 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
523 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
525 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
526 * in a separate chapter.
529 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
530 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
533 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
534 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
535 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
536 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
537 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
538 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
539 * determine the address as needed.
540 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
541 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating
542 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC.
543 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
544 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
545 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
546 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
548 struct vif_params {
549 u32 flags;
550 int use_4addr;
551 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
552 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
553 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
557 * struct key_params - key information
559 * Information about a key
561 * @key: key material
562 * @key_len: length of key material
563 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
564 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
565 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
566 * length given by @seq_len.
567 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
568 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
570 struct key_params {
571 const u8 *key;
572 const u8 *seq;
573 int key_len;
574 int seq_len;
575 u32 cipher;
576 enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
580 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
581 * @chan: the (control) channel
582 * @width: channel width
583 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
584 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
585 * (only with 80+80 MHz)
586 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
587 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
588 * chan will define the primary channel and all other
589 * parameters are ignored.
591 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
592 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
593 enum nl80211_chan_width width;
594 u32 center_freq1;
595 u32 center_freq2;
596 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
600 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
601 * @chandef: the channel definition
603 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
604 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
606 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
607 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
609 switch (chandef->width) {
610 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
611 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
612 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
613 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
614 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
615 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
616 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
617 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
618 default:
619 WARN_ON(1);
620 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
625 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
626 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
627 * @channel: the control channel
628 * @chantype: the channel type
630 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
632 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
633 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
634 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
637 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
638 * @chandef1: first channel definition
639 * @chandef2: second channel definition
641 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
642 * identical, %false otherwise.
644 static inline bool
645 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
646 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
648 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
649 chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
650 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
651 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
655 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
657 * @chandef: the channel definition
659 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
661 static inline bool
662 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
664 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
668 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
669 * @chandef1: first channel definition
670 * @chandef2: second channel definition
672 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
673 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
675 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
676 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
677 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
680 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
681 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
682 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
684 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
687 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
688 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
689 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
690 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
691 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
693 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
694 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
695 u32 prohibited_flags);
698 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
699 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
700 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
701 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
702 * Returns:
703 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
705 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
706 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
707 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
710 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
712 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
713 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
715 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
717 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
719 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
720 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
722 switch (chandef->width) {
723 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
724 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
725 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
726 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
727 default:
728 break;
730 return 0;
734 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
736 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
737 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
738 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
740 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
742 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
744 static inline int
745 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
747 switch (chandef->width) {
748 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
749 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
750 chandef->chan->max_power);
751 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
752 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
753 chandef->chan->max_power);
754 default:
755 break;
757 return chandef->chan->max_power;
761 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
763 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
764 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
765 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
766 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
767 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
768 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
769 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
770 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
771 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
773 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
774 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
776 enum survey_info_flags {
777 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0),
778 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1),
779 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2),
780 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3),
781 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4),
782 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5),
783 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6),
784 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7),
785 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8),
789 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
791 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
792 * record to report global statistics
793 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
794 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
795 * optional
796 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
797 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
798 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
799 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
800 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
801 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
802 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
804 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
806 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
807 * channel duty cycle etc.
809 struct survey_info {
810 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
811 u64 time;
812 u64 time_busy;
813 u64 time_ext_busy;
814 u64 time_rx;
815 u64 time_tx;
816 u64 time_scan;
817 u64 time_bss_rx;
818 u32 filled;
819 s8 noise;
822 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4
825 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
826 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
827 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
828 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
829 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
830 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
831 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
832 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
833 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
834 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
835 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
836 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
837 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
838 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports
839 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
840 * protocol frames.
841 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
842 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
843 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
844 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
845 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
846 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
847 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
848 * offload)
849 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
851 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
852 u32 wpa_versions;
853 u32 cipher_group;
854 int n_ciphers_pairwise;
855 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
856 int n_akm_suites;
857 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
858 bool control_port;
859 __be16 control_port_ethertype;
860 bool control_port_no_encrypt;
861 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
862 struct key_params *wep_keys;
863 int wep_tx_key;
864 const u8 *psk;
865 const u8 *sae_pwd;
866 u8 sae_pwd_len;
870 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
871 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
872 * or %NULL if not changed
873 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
874 * or %NULL if not changed
875 * @head_len: length of @head
876 * @tail_len: length of @tail
877 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
878 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
879 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
880 * frames or %NULL
881 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
882 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
883 * Response frames or %NULL
884 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
885 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
886 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
887 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
888 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
889 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
890 * (measurement type 8)
891 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
892 * Token (measurement type 11)
893 * @lci_len: LCI data length
894 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
896 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
897 const u8 *head, *tail;
898 const u8 *beacon_ies;
899 const u8 *proberesp_ies;
900 const u8 *assocresp_ies;
901 const u8 *probe_resp;
902 const u8 *lci;
903 const u8 *civicloc;
904 s8 ftm_responder;
906 size_t head_len, tail_len;
907 size_t beacon_ies_len;
908 size_t proberesp_ies_len;
909 size_t assocresp_ies_len;
910 size_t probe_resp_len;
911 size_t lci_len;
912 size_t civicloc_len;
915 struct mac_address {
916 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
920 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
922 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
923 * entry specified by mac_addr
924 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
925 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
927 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
928 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
929 int n_acl_entries;
931 /* Keep it last */
932 struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
936 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
938 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
939 struct {
940 u32 legacy;
941 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
942 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
943 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
944 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
948 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
950 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
952 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
954 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
955 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
959 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
961 * Used to configure an AP interface.
963 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
964 * @beacon: beacon data
965 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
966 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
967 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
968 * user space)
969 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
970 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
971 * @crypto: crypto settings
972 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
973 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
974 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
975 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
976 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
977 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
978 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
979 * MAC address based access control
980 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
981 * networks.
982 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
983 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
984 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
985 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
986 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
987 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
988 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
989 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
990 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
992 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
993 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
995 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
997 int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
998 const u8 *ssid;
999 size_t ssid_len;
1000 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1001 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1002 bool privacy;
1003 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1004 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1005 int inactivity_timeout;
1006 u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1007 bool p2p_opp_ps;
1008 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1009 bool pbss;
1010 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1012 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1013 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1014 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1015 bool ht_required, vht_required;
1016 bool twt_responder;
1017 u32 flags;
1018 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1022 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1024 * Used for channel switch
1026 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1027 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1028 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1029 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1030 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1031 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1032 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1033 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1034 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1035 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1037 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1038 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1039 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1040 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1041 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1042 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1043 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1044 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1045 bool radar_required;
1046 bool block_tx;
1047 u8 count;
1050 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10
1053 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1055 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1057 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1058 * to use for verification
1059 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1060 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1061 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1062 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1063 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1064 * nl80211_iftype.
1065 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1066 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1067 * the verification
1069 struct iface_combination_params {
1070 int num_different_channels;
1071 u8 radar_detect;
1072 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1073 u32 new_beacon_int;
1077 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1078 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1079 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1080 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1082 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1083 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1085 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1086 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1087 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1088 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1089 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1093 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1095 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1097 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1098 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1099 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1100 * power per-interface or per-station.
1101 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1102 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1103 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1104 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1105 * per peer TPC.
1107 struct sta_txpwr {
1108 s16 power;
1109 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1113 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1115 * Used to change and create a new station.
1117 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1118 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1119 * (or NULL for no change)
1120 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1121 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1122 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1123 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1124 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1125 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1126 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1127 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1128 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1129 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1130 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1131 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1132 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1133 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1134 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1135 * QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1136 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1137 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1138 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1139 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1140 * to unknown)
1141 * @capability: station capability
1142 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1143 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1144 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1145 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1146 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1147 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1148 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1149 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1150 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1151 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1152 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1153 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1155 struct station_parameters {
1156 const u8 *supported_rates;
1157 struct net_device *vlan;
1158 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1159 u32 sta_modify_mask;
1160 int listen_interval;
1161 u16 aid;
1162 u16 peer_aid;
1163 u8 supported_rates_len;
1164 u8 plink_action;
1165 u8 plink_state;
1166 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1167 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1168 u8 uapsd_queues;
1169 u8 max_sp;
1170 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1171 u16 capability;
1172 const u8 *ext_capab;
1173 u8 ext_capab_len;
1174 const u8 *supported_channels;
1175 u8 supported_channels_len;
1176 const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1177 u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1178 u8 opmode_notif;
1179 bool opmode_notif_used;
1180 int support_p2p_ps;
1181 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1182 u8 he_capa_len;
1183 u16 airtime_weight;
1184 struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1188 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1190 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1192 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1193 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1194 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1195 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1197 struct station_del_parameters {
1198 const u8 *mac;
1199 u8 subtype;
1200 u16 reason_code;
1204 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1205 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1206 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1207 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1208 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1209 * the AP MLME in the device
1210 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1211 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1212 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1213 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1214 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1215 * supported/used)
1216 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1217 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1218 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1219 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1221 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1222 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1223 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1224 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1225 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1226 CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1227 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1228 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1229 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1230 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1234 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1235 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1236 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1237 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1239 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1240 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1241 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1242 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1243 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1245 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1246 struct station_parameters *params,
1247 enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1250 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags
1252 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1253 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1255 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1256 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1257 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1258 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1259 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1260 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1262 enum rate_info_flags {
1263 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0),
1264 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1),
1265 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1266 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3),
1267 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4),
1268 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5),
1272 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1274 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1276 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1277 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1278 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1279 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1280 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1281 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1282 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1284 enum rate_info_bw {
1285 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1286 RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1287 RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1288 RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1289 RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1290 RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1291 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1295 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1297 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1299 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1300 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1301 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1302 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1303 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1304 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1305 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1306 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1307 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1308 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1310 struct rate_info {
1311 u8 flags;
1312 u8 mcs;
1313 u16 legacy;
1314 u8 nss;
1315 u8 bw;
1316 u8 he_gi;
1317 u8 he_dcm;
1318 u8 he_ru_alloc;
1319 u8 n_bonded_ch;
1323 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags
1325 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1326 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1328 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1329 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1330 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1332 enum bss_param_flags {
1333 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0,
1334 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1,
1335 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2,
1339 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1341 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1343 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1344 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1345 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1347 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1348 u8 flags;
1349 u8 dtim_period;
1350 u16 beacon_interval;
1354 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1355 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1356 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1357 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1358 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1359 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1360 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1361 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1362 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1363 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1364 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1365 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1366 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1367 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1369 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1370 u32 filled;
1371 u32 backlog_bytes;
1372 u32 backlog_packets;
1373 u32 flows;
1374 u32 drops;
1375 u32 ecn_marks;
1376 u32 overlimit;
1377 u32 overmemory;
1378 u32 collisions;
1379 u32 tx_bytes;
1380 u32 tx_packets;
1381 u32 max_flows;
1385 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1386 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1387 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1388 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1389 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1390 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1391 * transmitted MSDUs
1392 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1393 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1395 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1396 u32 filled;
1397 u64 rx_msdu;
1398 u64 tx_msdu;
1399 u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1400 u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1401 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1404 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4
1407 * struct station_info - station information
1409 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1411 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1412 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1413 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1414 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1415 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1416 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1417 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1418 * @llid: mesh local link id
1419 * @plid: mesh peer link id
1420 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1421 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1422 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1423 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1424 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1425 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1426 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1427 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1428 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1429 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1430 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1431 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1432 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1433 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1434 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason.
1435 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1436 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1437 * This number should increase every time the list of stations
1438 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1439 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1440 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1441 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1442 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1443 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1444 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1445 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1446 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1447 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1448 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1449 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1450 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1451 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1452 * towards this station.
1453 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1454 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1455 * from this peer
1456 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1457 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1458 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1459 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1460 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1461 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1462 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1463 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1464 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1465 * been sent.
1466 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1467 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1468 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1469 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1470 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1472 struct station_info {
1473 u64 filled;
1474 u32 connected_time;
1475 u32 inactive_time;
1476 u64 assoc_at;
1477 u64 rx_bytes;
1478 u64 tx_bytes;
1479 u16 llid;
1480 u16 plid;
1481 u8 plink_state;
1482 s8 signal;
1483 s8 signal_avg;
1485 u8 chains;
1486 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1487 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1489 struct rate_info txrate;
1490 struct rate_info rxrate;
1491 u32 rx_packets;
1492 u32 tx_packets;
1493 u32 tx_retries;
1494 u32 tx_failed;
1495 u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1496 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1497 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1499 int generation;
1501 const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1502 size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1504 u32 beacon_loss_count;
1505 s64 t_offset;
1506 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1507 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1508 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1510 u32 expected_throughput;
1512 u64 tx_duration;
1513 u64 rx_duration;
1514 u64 rx_beacon;
1515 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1516 u8 connected_to_gate;
1518 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1519 s8 ack_signal;
1520 s8 avg_ack_signal;
1522 u16 airtime_weight;
1524 u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1525 u32 fcs_err_count;
1527 u32 airtime_link_metric;
1530 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1532 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1533 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1534 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1535 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1537 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1538 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1539 * considered undefined.
1541 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1542 struct station_info *sinfo);
1543 #else
1544 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1545 const u8 *mac_addr,
1546 struct station_info *sinfo)
1548 return -ENOENT;
1550 #endif
1553 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1555 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1556 * according to the nl80211 flags.
1558 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1559 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1560 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1561 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1562 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1563 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1564 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1566 enum monitor_flags {
1567 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1568 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1569 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1570 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1571 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1572 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1573 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1577 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags
1579 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1580 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1582 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1583 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1584 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1585 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1586 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1587 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1588 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1589 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1590 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1592 enum mpath_info_flags {
1593 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0),
1594 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1),
1595 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2),
1596 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3),
1597 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4),
1598 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5),
1599 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6),
1600 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7),
1601 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8),
1605 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1607 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1609 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1610 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1611 * @sn: target sequence number
1612 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1613 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1614 * @flags: mesh path flags
1615 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1616 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1617 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1618 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1619 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1620 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1621 * @hop_count: hops to destination
1622 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1624 struct mpath_info {
1625 u32 filled;
1626 u32 frame_qlen;
1627 u32 sn;
1628 u32 metric;
1629 u32 exptime;
1630 u32 discovery_timeout;
1631 u8 discovery_retries;
1632 u8 flags;
1633 u8 hop_count;
1634 u32 path_change_count;
1636 int generation;
1640 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1642 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1644 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1645 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1646 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1647 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1648 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1649 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1650 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1651 * (or NULL for no change)
1652 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1653 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1654 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1655 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1656 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1657 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1659 struct bss_parameters {
1660 int use_cts_prot;
1661 int use_short_preamble;
1662 int use_short_slot_time;
1663 const u8 *basic_rates;
1664 u8 basic_rates_len;
1665 int ap_isolate;
1666 int ht_opmode;
1667 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1671 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1673 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1675 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1676 * by the Mesh Peering Open message
1677 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1678 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1679 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1680 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1681 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1682 * mesh interface
1683 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1684 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1685 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1686 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1687 * elements
1688 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1689 * detect compatible mesh peers
1690 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1691 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1692 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1693 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1694 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1695 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1696 * a path discovery in milliseconds
1697 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1698 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1699 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1700 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1701 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1702 * element
1703 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1704 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1705 * element
1706 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1707 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1708 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1709 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1710 * announcements are transmitted
1711 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1712 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1713 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1714 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1715 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1716 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1717 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1718 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1719 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1720 * station to establish a peer link
1721 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1723 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1724 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1725 * the root mesh STA to be valid.
1727 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1728 * PREQs are transmitted.
1729 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1730 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1731 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1732 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1733 * setting for new peer links.
1734 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1735 * after transmitting its beacon.
1736 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1737 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
1738 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes.
1739 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
1740 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the
1741 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
1742 * in the mesh path table
1744 struct mesh_config {
1745 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
1746 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
1747 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
1748 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
1749 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
1750 u8 dot11MeshTTL;
1751 u8 element_ttl;
1752 bool auto_open_plinks;
1753 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
1754 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
1755 u32 path_refresh_time;
1756 u16 min_discovery_timeout;
1757 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
1758 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
1759 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
1760 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
1761 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
1762 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
1763 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
1764 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
1765 bool dot11MeshForwarding;
1766 s32 rssi_threshold;
1767 u16 ht_opmode;
1768 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
1769 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
1770 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
1771 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
1772 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
1773 u32 plink_timeout;
1777 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
1778 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1779 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
1780 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
1781 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
1782 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
1783 * @path_metric: which metric to use
1784 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
1785 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
1786 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
1787 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
1788 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
1789 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
1790 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
1791 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
1792 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
1793 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
1794 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1795 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
1796 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
1797 * to operate on DFS channels.
1798 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1799 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1801 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
1803 struct mesh_setup {
1804 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1805 const u8 *mesh_id;
1806 u8 mesh_id_len;
1807 u8 sync_method;
1808 u8 path_sel_proto;
1809 u8 path_metric;
1810 u8 auth_id;
1811 const u8 *ie;
1812 u8 ie_len;
1813 bool is_authenticated;
1814 bool is_secure;
1815 bool user_mpm;
1816 u8 dtim_period;
1817 u16 beacon_interval;
1818 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1819 u32 basic_rates;
1820 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1821 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
1822 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1826 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
1827 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1829 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
1831 struct ocb_setup {
1832 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1836 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
1837 * @ac: AC identifier
1838 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
1839 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
1840 * 1..32767]
1841 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
1842 * 1..32767]
1843 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
1845 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
1846 enum nl80211_ac ac;
1847 u16 txop;
1848 u16 cwmin;
1849 u16 cwmax;
1850 u8 aifs;
1854 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
1856 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
1857 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
1858 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
1859 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
1860 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
1861 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
1862 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
1863 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
1864 * in the wiphy structure.
1866 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
1867 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
1868 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
1870 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
1871 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
1872 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
1873 * to userspace.
1877 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
1878 * @ssid: the SSID
1879 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
1881 struct cfg80211_ssid {
1882 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1883 u8 ssid_len;
1887 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
1888 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
1889 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
1890 * information is not available, this field is left zero.
1891 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
1892 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
1893 * userspace will be notified of that
1895 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
1896 u64 scan_start_tsf;
1897 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1898 bool aborted;
1902 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
1904 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
1905 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
1906 * @channels: channels to scan on.
1907 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
1908 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
1909 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
1910 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
1911 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
1912 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
1913 * the actual dwell time may be shorter.
1914 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
1915 * %duration field.
1916 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
1917 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
1918 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
1919 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
1920 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
1921 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
1922 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
1923 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
1924 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
1925 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
1926 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
1927 * be taken from the @mac_addr
1928 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
1930 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
1931 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
1932 int n_ssids;
1933 u32 n_channels;
1934 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
1935 const u8 *ie;
1936 size_t ie_len;
1937 u16 duration;
1938 bool duration_mandatory;
1939 u32 flags;
1941 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1943 struct wireless_dev *wdev;
1945 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1946 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1947 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1949 /* internal */
1950 struct wiphy *wiphy;
1951 unsigned long scan_start;
1952 struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
1953 bool notified;
1954 bool no_cck;
1956 /* keep last */
1957 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[0];
1960 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
1962 int i;
1964 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
1965 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
1966 buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
1967 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
1972 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
1974 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
1975 * or no match (RSSI only)
1976 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
1977 * or no match (RSSI only)
1978 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
1979 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
1980 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
1981 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
1982 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
1983 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
1984 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
1985 * corresponding matchset.
1987 struct cfg80211_match_set {
1988 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
1989 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
1990 s32 rssi_thold;
1991 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1995 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
1997 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
1998 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
1999 * infinite loop.
2000 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2001 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2003 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2004 u32 interval;
2005 u32 iterations;
2009 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2011 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2012 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2014 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2015 enum nl80211_band band;
2016 s8 delta;
2020 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2022 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2023 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2024 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2025 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2026 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2027 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2028 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2029 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2030 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2031 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2032 * (others are filtered out).
2033 * If ommited, all results are passed.
2034 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2035 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2036 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2037 * @dev: the interface
2038 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2039 * @channels: channels to scan
2040 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2041 * contains the minimum over all matchsets
2042 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2043 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2044 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2045 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2046 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2047 * index must be executed first.
2048 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2049 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2050 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2051 * owned by a particular socket)
2052 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2053 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2054 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2055 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2056 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2057 * supported.
2058 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2059 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2060 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2061 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2062 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2063 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2064 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2065 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2066 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2067 * comparisions.
2069 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2070 u64 reqid;
2071 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2072 int n_ssids;
2073 u32 n_channels;
2074 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2075 const u8 *ie;
2076 size_t ie_len;
2077 u32 flags;
2078 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2079 int n_match_sets;
2080 s32 min_rssi_thold;
2081 u32 delay;
2082 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2083 int n_scan_plans;
2085 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2086 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2088 bool relative_rssi_set;
2089 s8 relative_rssi;
2090 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2092 /* internal */
2093 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2094 struct net_device *dev;
2095 unsigned long scan_start;
2096 bool report_results;
2097 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2098 u32 owner_nlportid;
2099 bool nl_owner_dead;
2100 struct list_head list;
2102 /* keep last */
2103 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[0];
2107 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2109 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2110 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2111 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2113 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2114 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2115 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2116 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2120 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2121 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2122 * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2123 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2124 * signal type
2125 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2126 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2127 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2128 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2129 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2130 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2131 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2132 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2133 * by %parent_bssid.
2134 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2135 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2136 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2137 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2139 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2140 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2141 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2142 s32 signal;
2143 u64 boottime_ns;
2144 u64 parent_tsf;
2145 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2146 u8 chains;
2147 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2151 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2152 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2153 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2154 * @len: length of the IEs
2155 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2156 * @data: IE data
2158 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2159 u64 tsf;
2160 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2161 int len;
2162 bool from_beacon;
2163 u8 data[];
2167 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2169 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2170 * for use in scan results and similar.
2172 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2173 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2174 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2175 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2176 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2177 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2178 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2179 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2180 * received. It is always non-%NULL.
2181 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2182 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2183 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2184 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2185 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2186 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2187 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2188 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2189 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2190 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2191 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2192 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2193 * (multi-BSSID support)
2194 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2195 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2196 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2197 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2198 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2199 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2201 struct cfg80211_bss {
2202 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2203 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2205 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2206 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2207 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2209 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2210 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2211 struct list_head nontrans_list;
2213 s32 signal;
2215 u16 beacon_interval;
2216 u16 capability;
2218 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2219 u8 chains;
2220 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2222 u8 bssid_index;
2223 u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2225 u8 priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2229 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2230 * @bss: the bss to search
2231 * @id: the element ID
2233 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2234 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2235 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2237 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2240 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2241 * @bss: the bss to search
2242 * @id: the element ID
2244 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2245 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2246 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2248 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2250 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2255 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2257 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2258 * authentication.
2260 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2261 * to it if it needs to keep it.
2262 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2263 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2264 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2265 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2266 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2267 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2268 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2269 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2270 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2271 * transaction sequence number field.
2272 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2274 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2275 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2276 const u8 *ie;
2277 size_t ie_len;
2278 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2279 const u8 *key;
2280 u8 key_len, key_idx;
2281 const u8 *auth_data;
2282 size_t auth_data_len;
2286 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2288 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n)
2289 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT
2290 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2291 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2292 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2293 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2294 * request (connect callback).
2296 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2297 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0),
2298 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1),
2299 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2),
2300 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3),
2304 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2306 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2307 * (re)association.
2308 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2309 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2310 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2311 * association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2312 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2313 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2314 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2315 * @crypto: crypto settings
2316 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2317 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2318 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2319 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2320 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2321 * frame.
2322 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2323 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
2324 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
2325 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2326 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2327 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2328 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2329 * %NULL if FILS is not used.
2330 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2331 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2332 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2333 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2335 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2336 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2337 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2338 size_t ie_len;
2339 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2340 bool use_mfp;
2341 u32 flags;
2342 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2343 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2344 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2345 const u8 *fils_kek;
2346 size_t fils_kek_len;
2347 const u8 *fils_nonces;
2351 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2353 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2354 * deauthentication.
2356 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2357 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2358 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2359 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2360 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2361 * do not set a deauth frame
2363 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2364 const u8 *bssid;
2365 const u8 *ie;
2366 size_t ie_len;
2367 u16 reason_code;
2368 bool local_state_change;
2372 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2374 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2375 * disassociation.
2377 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2378 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2379 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2380 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2381 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2382 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2384 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2385 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2386 const u8 *ie;
2387 size_t ie_len;
2388 u16 reason_code;
2389 bool local_state_change;
2393 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2395 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2396 * method.
2398 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2399 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2400 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2401 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2402 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2403 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2404 * IBSSs to join on other channels.
2405 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2406 * @ie_len: length of that
2407 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2408 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2409 * after joining
2410 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2411 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2412 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2413 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2414 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2415 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2416 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2417 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2418 * to operate on DFS channels.
2419 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2420 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2421 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
2422 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
2423 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2424 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2425 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2426 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2428 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2429 const u8 *ssid;
2430 const u8 *bssid;
2431 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2432 const u8 *ie;
2433 u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2434 u16 beacon_interval;
2435 u32 basic_rates;
2436 bool channel_fixed;
2437 bool privacy;
2438 bool control_port;
2439 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2440 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2441 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2442 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2443 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2444 struct key_params *wep_keys;
2445 int wep_tx_key;
2449 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2451 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2452 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2453 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2454 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2456 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2457 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2458 union {
2459 enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2460 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2461 } param;
2465 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2467 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2468 * authentication and association.
2470 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2471 * on scan results)
2472 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2473 * %NULL if not specified
2474 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2475 * results)
2476 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2477 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2478 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2479 * to use.
2480 * @ssid: SSID
2481 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2482 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2483 * @ie: IEs for association request
2484 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2485 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2486 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2487 * @crypto: crypto settings
2488 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2489 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2490 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2491 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2492 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds
2493 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2494 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
2495 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
2496 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2497 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides
2498 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2499 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2500 * networks.
2501 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2502 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2503 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2504 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2505 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2506 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2507 * frame.
2508 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2509 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2510 * data IE.
2511 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2512 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2513 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2514 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2515 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2516 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2517 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2518 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2519 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2520 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2521 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2522 * offload of 4-way handshake.
2523 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2524 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2525 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2527 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2528 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2529 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2530 const u8 *bssid;
2531 const u8 *bssid_hint;
2532 const u8 *ssid;
2533 size_t ssid_len;
2534 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2535 const u8 *ie;
2536 size_t ie_len;
2537 bool privacy;
2538 enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2539 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2540 const u8 *key;
2541 u8 key_len, key_idx;
2542 u32 flags;
2543 int bg_scan_period;
2544 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2545 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2546 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2547 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2548 bool pbss;
2549 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2550 const u8 *prev_bssid;
2551 const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2552 size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2553 const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2554 size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2555 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2556 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2557 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2558 bool want_1x;
2559 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2563 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2565 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2566 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2568 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2569 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2570 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2571 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2573 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2574 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0),
2575 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1),
2576 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2),
2580 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2581 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2582 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2583 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2584 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2585 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2586 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2587 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2588 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2589 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2591 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2592 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0,
2593 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1,
2594 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2,
2595 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3,
2596 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4,
2597 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5,
2598 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6,
2599 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7,
2600 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8,
2603 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256
2606 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2608 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2609 * caching.
2611 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2612 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2613 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2614 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2615 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2616 * the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2617 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2618 * cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2619 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2620 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2621 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2622 * %NULL).
2624 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2625 const u8 *bssid;
2626 const u8 *pmkid;
2627 const u8 *pmk;
2628 size_t pmk_len;
2629 const u8 *ssid;
2630 size_t ssid_len;
2631 const u8 *cache_id;
2635 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2636 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2637 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2638 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2639 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2640 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2642 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2643 * memory, free @mask only!
2645 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2646 const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2647 int pattern_len;
2648 int pkt_offset;
2652 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2654 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2655 * @src: source IP address
2656 * @dst: destination IP address
2657 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2658 * @src_port: source port
2659 * @dst_port: destination port
2660 * @payload_len: data payload length
2661 * @payload: data payload buffer
2662 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2663 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2664 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2665 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2666 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2667 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2668 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2670 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2671 struct socket *sock;
2672 __be32 src, dst;
2673 u16 src_port, dst_port;
2674 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2675 int payload_len;
2676 const u8 *payload;
2677 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
2678 u32 data_interval;
2679 u32 wake_len;
2680 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
2681 u32 tokens_size;
2682 /* must be last, variable member */
2683 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
2687 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
2689 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
2690 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
2691 * operating as normal during suspend
2692 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
2693 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
2694 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
2695 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2696 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
2697 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
2698 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
2699 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
2700 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
2701 * NULL if not configured.
2702 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
2704 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
2705 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
2706 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
2707 rfkill_release;
2708 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2709 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
2710 int n_patterns;
2711 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
2715 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
2717 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
2718 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
2719 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
2720 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
2721 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
2722 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2724 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
2725 int delay;
2726 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
2727 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2728 int n_patterns;
2732 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
2734 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
2735 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
2736 * @n_rules: number of rules
2738 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
2739 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
2740 int n_rules;
2744 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
2746 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
2747 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This
2748 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
2749 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
2750 * occurred (in MHz)
2752 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
2753 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2754 int n_channels;
2755 u32 channels[];
2759 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
2761 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
2762 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
2763 * match information.
2764 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
2765 * the matches that triggered the wake up.
2767 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
2768 int n_matches;
2769 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
2773 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
2774 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
2775 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
2776 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
2777 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
2778 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
2779 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
2780 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
2781 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
2782 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
2783 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
2784 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data
2785 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
2786 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
2787 * it is.
2788 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
2789 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
2790 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
2791 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
2793 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
2794 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
2795 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
2796 rfkill_release, packet_80211,
2797 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
2798 s32 pattern_idx;
2799 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
2800 const void *packet;
2801 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
2805 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
2806 * @kek: key encryption key (NL80211_KEK_LEN bytes)
2807 * @kck: key confirmation key (NL80211_KCK_LEN bytes)
2808 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
2810 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
2811 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
2815 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
2817 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
2819 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
2820 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
2821 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
2823 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
2824 u16 md;
2825 const u8 *ie;
2826 size_t ie_len;
2830 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
2832 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
2834 * @chan: channel to use
2835 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
2836 * @wait: duration for ROC
2837 * @buf: buffer to transmit
2838 * @len: buffer length
2839 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
2840 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
2841 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
2842 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
2844 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
2845 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2846 bool offchan;
2847 unsigned int wait;
2848 const u8 *buf;
2849 size_t len;
2850 bool no_cck;
2851 bool dont_wait_for_ack;
2852 int n_csa_offsets;
2853 const u16 *csa_offsets;
2857 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
2859 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
2860 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
2862 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
2863 u8 dscp;
2864 u8 up;
2868 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
2870 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
2871 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
2873 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
2874 u8 low;
2875 u8 high;
2878 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
2879 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21
2880 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16
2881 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
2882 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
2885 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
2887 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
2889 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
2890 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
2891 * the user priority DSCP range definition
2892 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
2894 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
2895 u8 num_des;
2896 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
2897 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
2901 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
2903 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
2905 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
2906 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
2907 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
2908 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
2910 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
2911 u8 master_pref;
2912 u8 bands;
2916 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
2917 * configuration
2919 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
2920 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
2922 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
2923 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
2924 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
2928 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
2930 * @filter: the content of the filter
2931 * @len: the length of the filter
2933 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
2934 const u8 *filter;
2935 u8 len;
2939 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
2941 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
2942 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
2943 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
2944 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
2945 * implementation specific.
2946 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
2947 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
2948 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
2949 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
2950 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
2951 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
2952 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
2953 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
2954 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
2955 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
2956 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
2957 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
2958 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
2959 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
2960 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
2961 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
2962 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
2963 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
2964 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
2965 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
2967 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
2968 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
2969 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
2970 u8 publish_type;
2971 bool close_range;
2972 bool publish_bcast;
2973 bool subscribe_active;
2974 u8 followup_id;
2975 u8 followup_reqid;
2976 struct mac_address followup_dest;
2977 u32 ttl;
2978 const u8 *serv_spec_info;
2979 u8 serv_spec_info_len;
2980 bool srf_include;
2981 const u8 *srf_bf;
2982 u8 srf_bf_len;
2983 u8 srf_bf_idx;
2984 struct mac_address *srf_macs;
2985 int srf_num_macs;
2986 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
2987 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
2988 u8 num_tx_filters;
2989 u8 num_rx_filters;
2990 u8 instance_id;
2991 u64 cookie;
2995 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
2997 * @aa: authenticator address
2998 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
2999 * @pmk: the PMK material
3000 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3001 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3002 * holds PMK-R0.
3004 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3005 const u8 *aa;
3006 u8 pmk_len;
3007 const u8 *pmk;
3008 const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3012 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3014 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3016 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3017 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3018 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3019 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3020 * authentication response command interface.
3021 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and
3022 * authentication response command interface.
3023 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3024 * authentication request event interface.
3025 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3026 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3027 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3028 * response command interface (user space to driver).
3029 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3031 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3032 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3033 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3034 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3035 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3036 u16 status;
3037 const u8 *pmkid;
3041 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3043 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3044 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3045 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3046 * answered
3047 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3048 * successfully answered
3049 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3050 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3051 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions
3052 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3053 * of how much time the responder was busy
3054 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3055 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3056 * the responder
3057 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3058 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3059 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3061 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3062 u32 filled;
3063 u32 success_num;
3064 u32 partial_num;
3065 u32 failed_num;
3066 u32 asap_num;
3067 u32 non_asap_num;
3068 u64 total_duration_ms;
3069 u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3070 u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3071 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3075 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3076 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3077 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3078 * reason than just "failure"
3079 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3080 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3081 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3082 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3083 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3084 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3085 * by the responder
3086 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3087 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3088 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3089 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3090 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3091 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3092 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3093 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3094 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3095 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3096 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3097 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3098 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3099 * the square root of the variance)
3100 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3101 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3102 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3103 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3104 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3105 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3106 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3107 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3108 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3109 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3110 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3111 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3112 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3113 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3114 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3115 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3116 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3118 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3119 const u8 *lci;
3120 const u8 *civicloc;
3121 unsigned int lci_len;
3122 unsigned int civicloc_len;
3123 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3124 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3125 s16 burst_index;
3126 u8 busy_retry_time;
3127 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3128 u8 burst_duration;
3129 u8 ftms_per_burst;
3130 s32 rssi_avg;
3131 s32 rssi_spread;
3132 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3133 s64 rtt_avg;
3134 s64 rtt_variance;
3135 s64 rtt_spread;
3136 s64 dist_avg;
3137 s64 dist_variance;
3138 s64 dist_spread;
3140 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3141 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3142 rssi_avg_valid:1,
3143 rssi_spread_valid:1,
3144 tx_rate_valid:1,
3145 rx_rate_valid:1,
3146 rtt_avg_valid:1,
3147 rtt_variance_valid:1,
3148 rtt_spread_valid:1,
3149 dist_avg_valid:1,
3150 dist_variance_valid:1,
3151 dist_spread_valid:1;
3155 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3156 * @addr: address of the peer
3157 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3158 * measurement was made)
3159 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3160 * @status: status of the measurement
3161 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3162 * reporting partial results always set this flag
3163 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3164 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3165 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3166 * they're all aggregated for userspace.
3168 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3169 u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3170 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3172 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3174 u8 final:1,
3175 ap_tsf_valid:1;
3177 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3179 union {
3180 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3185 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3186 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3187 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3188 * @burst_period: burst period to use
3189 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3190 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3191 * @burst_duration: burst duration
3192 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3193 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3194 * @request_lci: request LCI information
3195 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3197 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3199 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3200 enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3201 u16 burst_period;
3202 u8 requested:1,
3203 asap:1,
3204 request_lci:1,
3205 request_civicloc:1;
3206 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3207 u8 burst_duration;
3208 u8 ftms_per_burst;
3209 u8 ftmr_retries;
3213 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3214 * @addr: MAC address
3215 * @chandef: channel to use
3216 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3217 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3219 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3220 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3221 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3222 u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3223 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3227 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3228 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3229 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3230 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3231 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3232 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3233 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3234 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3235 * be taken from the @mac_addr
3236 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3237 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3238 * zero it means there's no timeout
3239 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3240 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3242 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3243 u64 cookie;
3244 void *drv_data;
3245 u32 n_peers;
3246 u32 nl_portid;
3248 u32 timeout;
3250 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3251 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3253 struct list_head list;
3255 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3259 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3261 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3262 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3264 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3266 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3267 * has to be done.
3268 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3269 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3270 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3271 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3272 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3273 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3274 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3275 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3277 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3278 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3279 u16 status;
3280 const u8 *ie;
3281 size_t ie_len;
3285 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3287 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3288 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3290 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3291 * on success or a negative error code.
3293 * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the
3294 * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this
3295 * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext.
3297 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3298 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3299 * configured for the device.
3300 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3301 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3302 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3303 * the device.
3305 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3306 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3307 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3308 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3309 * also set the address member in the wdev.
3311 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3313 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3314 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3316 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3317 * when adding a group key.
3319 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3320 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3321 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3322 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3323 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3325 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3326 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3328 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3330 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3332 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3334 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3335 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3336 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3337 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3339 * @add_station: Add a new station.
3340 * @del_station: Remove a station
3341 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3342 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3343 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3344 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3345 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3346 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3347 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3349 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3350 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3351 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3352 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3353 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3354 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3355 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3356 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3357 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3358 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3359 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3361 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3363 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3364 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3365 * set, and which to leave alone.
3367 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3369 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3371 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3372 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3373 * join the mesh instead.
3375 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3376 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3377 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3378 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3380 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3381 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3382 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3383 * the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3384 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3385 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3387 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3388 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3389 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3390 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3391 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3392 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3393 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3394 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3396 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3397 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3398 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3399 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3400 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3401 * was received.
3402 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3403 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3404 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3405 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3406 * frame instead of Association Request frame.
3407 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3408 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3409 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3410 * indication of requesting reassociation.
3411 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3412 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3413 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3414 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3415 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3416 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3417 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3418 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3419 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3420 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3421 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3422 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3423 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3424 * case connection was already established (invoked with the
3425 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3427 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3428 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3429 * to a merge.
3430 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3431 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3432 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3434 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3435 * MESH mode)
3437 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3438 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3439 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3440 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3442 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3443 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3444 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3445 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3446 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3447 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3448 * return 0 if successful
3450 * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface
3452 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3453 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3455 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3457 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3458 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3459 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3460 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3461 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3462 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3463 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3464 * the duration value.
3465 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3466 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3467 * frame on another channel
3469 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3470 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3471 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3472 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3473 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3474 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3475 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3477 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3479 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3480 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3481 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3482 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3483 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3484 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3485 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3486 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3487 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3488 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3489 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3490 * disabled.)
3491 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3492 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the
3493 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should
3494 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3495 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3496 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3497 * thresholds.
3498 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3499 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3500 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3501 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3502 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3503 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3504 * stop (when this method returns 0).
3506 * @mgmt_frame_register: Notify driver that a management frame type was
3507 * registered. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3509 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3510 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3511 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3512 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3514 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3516 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3517 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3519 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3520 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3522 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3524 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3525 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3526 * current monitoring channel.
3528 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3529 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3531 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3532 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3533 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3534 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3535 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3536 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3538 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3540 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3541 * was finished on another phy.
3543 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3544 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3545 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3547 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3548 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3549 * driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3550 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3551 * reliability. This operation can not fail.
3552 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3554 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3555 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3556 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3557 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3558 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3559 * as soon as possible.
3561 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3563 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3564 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3565 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3567 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3568 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3569 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3570 * account.
3571 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3572 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3573 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3574 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3575 * rejected)
3576 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3578 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3579 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3580 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3581 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3583 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3584 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3585 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3586 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3587 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3588 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3589 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3590 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3591 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3592 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3593 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3594 * cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3595 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3596 * provided @nan_func.
3597 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3598 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3599 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3600 * All other parameters must be ignored.
3602 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3604 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3605 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3607 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3608 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3609 * upon which the driver should clear it.
3610 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3611 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3612 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3614 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3615 * user space
3617 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter
3618 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3620 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3621 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3622 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3623 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3625 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3626 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3627 * DH IE through this interface.
3629 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3630 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3632 struct cfg80211_ops {
3633 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
3634 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3635 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
3637 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3638 const char *name,
3639 unsigned char name_assign_type,
3640 enum nl80211_iftype type,
3641 struct vif_params *params);
3642 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3643 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3644 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3645 struct net_device *dev,
3646 enum nl80211_iftype type,
3647 struct vif_params *params);
3649 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3650 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3651 struct key_params *params);
3652 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3653 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3654 void *cookie,
3655 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
3656 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3657 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
3658 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3659 struct net_device *netdev,
3660 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
3661 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3662 struct net_device *netdev,
3663 u8 key_index);
3665 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3666 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
3667 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3668 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
3669 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3672 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3673 const u8 *mac,
3674 struct station_parameters *params);
3675 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3676 struct station_del_parameters *params);
3677 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3678 const u8 *mac,
3679 struct station_parameters *params);
3680 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3681 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3682 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3683 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3685 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3686 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3687 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3688 const u8 *dst);
3689 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3690 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3691 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3692 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3693 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3694 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
3695 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3696 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3697 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3698 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3699 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
3700 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3701 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3702 struct net_device *dev,
3703 struct mesh_config *conf);
3704 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3705 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
3706 const struct mesh_config *nconf);
3707 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3708 const struct mesh_config *conf,
3709 const struct mesh_setup *setup);
3710 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3712 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3713 struct ocb_setup *setup);
3714 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3716 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3717 struct bss_parameters *params);
3719 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3720 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
3722 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3723 struct net_device *dev,
3724 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
3726 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3727 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3729 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3730 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
3731 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3733 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3734 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
3735 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3736 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
3737 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3738 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
3739 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3740 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
3742 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3743 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
3744 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3745 struct net_device *dev,
3746 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
3747 u32 changed);
3748 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3749 u16 reason_code);
3751 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3752 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
3753 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3755 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3756 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
3758 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
3760 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3761 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
3762 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3763 int *dbm);
3765 int (*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3766 const u8 *addr);
3768 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3770 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
3771 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3772 void *data, int len);
3773 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
3774 struct netlink_callback *cb,
3775 void *data, int len);
3776 #endif
3778 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3779 struct net_device *dev,
3780 const u8 *peer,
3781 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
3783 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3784 int idx, struct survey_info *info);
3786 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3787 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
3788 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3789 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
3790 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
3792 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3793 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3794 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
3795 unsigned int duration,
3796 u64 *cookie);
3797 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3798 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3799 u64 cookie);
3801 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3802 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
3803 u64 *cookie);
3804 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3805 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3806 u64 cookie);
3808 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3809 bool enabled, int timeout);
3811 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3812 struct net_device *dev,
3813 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
3815 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3816 struct net_device *dev,
3817 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
3819 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3820 struct net_device *dev,
3821 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
3823 void (*mgmt_frame_register)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3824 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3825 u16 frame_type, bool reg);
3827 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
3828 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
3830 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3831 struct net_device *dev,
3832 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
3833 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3834 u64 reqid);
3836 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3837 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3839 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3840 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token,
3841 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
3842 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
3843 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3844 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
3846 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3847 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
3849 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3850 struct net_device *dev,
3851 u16 noack_map);
3853 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3854 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3855 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3857 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3858 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3859 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3860 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3862 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3863 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
3865 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3866 struct net_device *dev,
3867 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
3868 u32 cac_time_ms);
3869 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3870 struct net_device *dev);
3871 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3872 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
3873 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3874 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3875 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
3876 u16 duration);
3877 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3878 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3879 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3880 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
3882 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3883 struct net_device *dev,
3884 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
3886 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3887 struct net_device *dev,
3888 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
3890 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3891 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3893 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3894 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
3895 u16 admitted_time);
3896 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3897 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
3899 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3900 struct net_device *dev,
3901 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
3902 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3903 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3904 struct net_device *dev,
3905 const u8 *addr);
3906 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3907 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
3908 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3909 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3910 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
3911 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3912 u64 cookie);
3913 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3914 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3915 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
3916 u32 changes);
3918 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3919 struct net_device *dev,
3920 const bool enabled);
3922 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3923 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3924 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
3926 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3927 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
3928 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3929 const u8 *aa);
3930 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3931 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
3933 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3934 struct net_device *dev,
3935 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
3936 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
3937 const bool noencrypt);
3939 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3940 struct net_device *dev,
3941 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
3943 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3944 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
3945 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
3946 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
3947 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3948 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
3949 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3950 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
3954 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
3955 * and registration/helper functions
3959 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
3961 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
3962 * wiphy at all
3963 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
3964 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
3965 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
3966 * reason to override the default
3967 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
3968 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
3969 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
3970 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
3971 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
3972 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
3973 * control_port_no_encrypt flag.
3974 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
3975 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
3976 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
3977 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
3978 * firmware.
3979 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
3980 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
3981 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
3982 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
3983 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
3984 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
3985 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
3986 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
3987 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
3988 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
3989 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
3990 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
3991 * responds to probe-requests in hardware.
3992 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
3993 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
3994 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
3995 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
3996 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
3997 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
3998 * before connection.
4000 enum wiphy_flags {
4001 /* use hole at 0 */
4002 /* use hole at 1 */
4003 /* use hole at 2 */
4004 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3),
4005 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4),
4006 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5),
4007 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6),
4008 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7),
4009 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8),
4010 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10),
4011 /* use hole at 11 */
4012 /* use hole at 12 */
4013 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13),
4014 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14),
4015 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15),
4016 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16),
4017 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17),
4018 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18),
4019 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19),
4020 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20),
4021 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21),
4022 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22),
4023 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23),
4024 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24),
4028 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4029 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4030 * @types: interface types (bits)
4032 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4033 u16 max;
4034 u16 types;
4038 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4040 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4041 * combinations it supports concurrently.
4043 * Examples:
4045 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4047 * .. code-block:: c
4049 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4050 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4051 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4052 * };
4053 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4054 * .limits = limits1,
4055 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4056 * .max_interfaces = 2,
4057 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4058 * };
4061 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4063 * .. code-block:: c
4065 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4066 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4067 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4068 * };
4069 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4070 * .limits = limits2,
4071 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4072 * .max_interfaces = 8,
4073 * .num_different_channels = 1,
4074 * };
4077 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4079 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4081 * .. code-block:: c
4083 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4084 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4085 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4086 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4087 * };
4088 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4089 * .limits = limits3,
4090 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4091 * .max_interfaces = 4,
4092 * .num_different_channels = 2,
4093 * };
4096 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4098 * @limits:
4099 * limits for the given interface types
4101 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4104 * @num_different_channels:
4105 * can use up to this many different channels
4107 u32 num_different_channels;
4110 * @max_interfaces:
4111 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4113 u16 max_interfaces;
4116 * @n_limits:
4117 * number of limitations
4119 u8 n_limits;
4122 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4123 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4124 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4126 bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4129 * @radar_detect_widths:
4130 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4132 u8 radar_detect_widths;
4135 * @radar_detect_regions:
4136 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4138 u8 radar_detect_regions;
4141 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4142 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4144 * = 0
4145 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4146 * > 0
4147 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4148 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4149 * combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4151 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4154 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4155 u16 tx, rx;
4159 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4160 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4161 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4162 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4163 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4164 * packet should be preserved in that case
4165 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4166 * (see nl80211.h)
4167 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4168 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4169 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4170 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4171 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4172 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4173 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4175 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4176 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0),
4177 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1),
4178 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2),
4179 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3),
4180 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4),
4181 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5),
4182 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6),
4183 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7),
4184 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8),
4187 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4188 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4189 u32 data_payload_max;
4190 u32 data_interval_max;
4191 u32 wake_payload_max;
4192 bool seq;
4196 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4197 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4198 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4199 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4200 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4201 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4202 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4203 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4204 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4205 * scheduled scans.
4206 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4207 * details.
4208 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4210 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4211 u32 flags;
4212 int n_patterns;
4213 int pattern_max_len;
4214 int pattern_min_len;
4215 int max_pkt_offset;
4216 int max_nd_match_sets;
4217 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4221 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4222 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4223 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4224 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4225 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4226 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4227 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4228 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4230 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4231 int n_rules;
4232 int max_delay;
4233 int n_patterns;
4234 int pattern_max_len;
4235 int pattern_min_len;
4236 int max_pkt_offset;
4240 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4241 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4242 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4243 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4244 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4246 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4247 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4248 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4249 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4253 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4255 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4256 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4257 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4260 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4261 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
4262 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1),
4263 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2),
4267 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4268 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4269 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4270 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4271 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4274 struct sta_opmode_info {
4275 u32 changed;
4276 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4277 enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4278 u8 rx_nss;
4281 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4284 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4285 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4286 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4287 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4288 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4289 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4290 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4291 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4292 * dumpit calls.
4293 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4294 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4295 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4296 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4297 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4298 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4299 * are used with dump requests.
4301 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4302 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4303 u32 flags;
4304 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4305 const void *data, int data_len);
4306 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4307 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4308 unsigned long *storage);
4309 const struct nla_policy *policy;
4310 unsigned int maxattr;
4314 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4315 * @iftype: interface type
4316 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4317 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4318 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4319 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4320 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4321 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4322 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4324 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4325 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4326 const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4327 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4328 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4332 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4333 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4334 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4335 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4336 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4337 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4338 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4339 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4340 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4341 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4342 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4343 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4344 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4345 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4346 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4347 * not limited)
4349 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4350 unsigned int max_peers;
4351 u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4352 randomize_mac_addr:1;
4354 struct {
4355 u32 preambles;
4356 u32 bandwidths;
4357 s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4358 u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4359 u8 supported:1,
4360 asap:1,
4361 non_asap:1,
4362 request_lci:1,
4363 request_civicloc:1;
4364 } ftm;
4368 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4369 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4370 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4371 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4372 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4373 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4374 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4375 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4376 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4377 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4378 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4379 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites
4380 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4381 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4382 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4383 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4384 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4385 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4386 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4387 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4388 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4389 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4390 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4391 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4392 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4393 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4394 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4395 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4396 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4397 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4398 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4399 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4400 * unregister hardware
4401 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy, will be renamed
4402 * automatically on wiphy renames
4403 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy
4404 * @registered: helps synchronize suspend/resume with wiphy unregister
4405 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4406 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4407 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4408 * must be set by driver
4409 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4410 * list single interface types.
4411 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4412 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4413 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4414 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4415 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4416 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4417 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4418 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4419 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4420 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4421 * this variable determines its size
4422 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4423 * any given scan
4424 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4425 * the device can run concurrently.
4426 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4427 * for in any given scheduled scan
4428 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4429 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4430 * supported.
4431 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4432 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4433 * include fixed IEs like supported rates
4434 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4435 * scans
4436 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4437 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4438 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4439 * single scan plan supported by the device.
4440 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4441 * scan plan supported by the device.
4442 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4443 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4444 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4445 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4446 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4447 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4448 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4450 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4451 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4452 * type
4454 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4455 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4456 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4458 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4459 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4460 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4462 * @probe_resp_offload:
4463 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4464 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4465 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4467 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4468 * may request, if implemented.
4470 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4471 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4472 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4473 * to the suspend() operation instead.
4475 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4476 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4477 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4478 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4479 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4481 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4482 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4484 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4485 * supports for ACL.
4487 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4488 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4489 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4490 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4491 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4492 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4493 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4494 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4495 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4496 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4497 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4498 * capabilities are specified separately.
4499 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4501 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4502 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4503 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4504 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4506 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4507 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4508 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4509 * some cases, but may not always reach.
4511 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4512 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver
4513 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4514 * infinite.
4515 * @max_adj_channel_rssi_comp: max offset of between the channel on which the
4516 * frame was sent and the channel on which the frame was heard for which
4517 * the reported rssi is still valid. If a driver is able to compensate the
4518 * low rssi when a frame is heard on different channel, then it should set
4519 * this variable to the maximal offset for which it can compensate.
4520 * This value should be set in MHz.
4521 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4522 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4523 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4525 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4526 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for
4527 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4528 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4530 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4531 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4532 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4534 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4535 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4536 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4537 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4539 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4541 struct wiphy {
4542 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4544 /* permanent MAC address(es) */
4545 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4546 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4548 struct mac_address *addresses;
4550 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4552 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4553 int n_iface_combinations;
4554 u16 software_iftypes;
4556 u16 n_addresses;
4558 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4559 u16 interface_modes;
4561 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4563 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4564 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4566 u32 ap_sme_capa;
4568 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4570 int bss_priv_size;
4571 u8 max_scan_ssids;
4572 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4573 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4574 u8 max_match_sets;
4575 u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4576 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4577 u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4578 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4579 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4581 int n_cipher_suites;
4582 const u32 *cipher_suites;
4584 int n_akm_suites;
4585 const u32 *akm_suites;
4587 u8 retry_short;
4588 u8 retry_long;
4589 u32 frag_threshold;
4590 u32 rts_threshold;
4591 u8 coverage_class;
4593 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
4594 u32 hw_version;
4596 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4597 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
4598 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
4599 #endif
4601 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
4603 u8 max_num_pmkids;
4605 u32 available_antennas_tx;
4606 u32 available_antennas_rx;
4609 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading
4610 * see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4611 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4613 u32 probe_resp_offload;
4615 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
4616 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4618 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
4619 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
4621 /* If multiple wiphys are registered and you're handed e.g.
4622 * a regular netdev with assigned ieee80211_ptr, you won't
4623 * know whether it points to a wiphy your driver has registered
4624 * or not. Assign this to something global to your driver to
4625 * help determine whether you own this wiphy or not. */
4626 const void *privid;
4628 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
4630 /* Lets us get back the wiphy on the callback */
4631 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4632 struct regulatory_request *request);
4634 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
4636 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
4638 /* the item in /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this,
4639 * you need use set_wiphy_dev() (see below) */
4640 struct device dev;
4642 /* protects ->resume, ->suspend sysfs callbacks against unregister hw */
4643 bool registered;
4645 /* dir in debugfs: ieee80211/<wiphyname> */
4646 struct dentry *debugfsdir;
4648 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
4649 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
4651 struct list_head wdev_list;
4653 /* the network namespace this phy lives in currently */
4654 possible_net_t _net;
4656 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
4657 const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
4658 #endif
4660 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
4662 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
4663 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
4664 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
4666 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
4668 u8 max_num_csa_counters;
4669 u8 max_adj_channel_rssi_comp;
4671 u32 bss_select_support;
4673 u8 nan_supported_bands;
4675 u32 txq_limit;
4676 u32 txq_memory_limit;
4677 u32 txq_quantum;
4679 u8 support_mbssid:1,
4680 support_only_he_mbssid:1;
4682 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
4684 char priv[0] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
4687 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
4689 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
4692 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
4694 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
4698 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
4700 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
4701 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
4703 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
4705 BUG_ON(!wiphy);
4706 return &wiphy->priv;
4710 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
4712 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
4713 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
4715 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
4717 BUG_ON(!priv);
4718 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
4722 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
4724 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
4725 * @dev: The device to parent it to
4727 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
4729 wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
4733 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
4735 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
4736 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
4738 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
4740 return wiphy->dev.parent;
4744 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
4746 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
4747 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
4749 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
4751 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
4755 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
4757 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
4758 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
4759 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
4760 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
4762 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
4763 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
4765 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
4766 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
4768 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
4769 const char *requested_name);
4772 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
4774 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
4775 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
4777 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
4778 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
4780 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
4781 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
4783 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
4784 int sizeof_priv)
4786 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
4790 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
4792 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
4794 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
4796 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4799 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
4801 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
4803 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
4804 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
4805 * request that is being handled.
4807 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4810 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
4812 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
4814 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4816 /* internal structs */
4817 struct cfg80211_conn;
4818 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
4819 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
4820 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
4823 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
4825 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
4826 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
4827 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
4828 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
4829 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device.
4831 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
4832 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
4833 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
4834 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
4836 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
4837 * @iftype: interface type
4838 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
4839 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
4840 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
4841 * wireless device if it has no netdev
4842 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4843 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
4844 * the user-set channel definition.
4845 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
4846 * track the channel to be used for AP later
4847 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4848 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4849 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4850 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4851 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
4852 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
4853 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
4854 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
4855 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
4856 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
4857 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
4858 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
4859 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
4860 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
4861 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
4862 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
4863 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
4864 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
4865 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
4866 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
4867 * by cfg80211 on change_interface
4868 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
4869 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
4870 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
4871 * and some API functions require it held
4872 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
4873 * beacons, 0 when not valid
4874 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
4875 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
4876 * the P2P Device.
4877 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
4878 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
4879 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
4880 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
4881 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
4882 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
4883 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
4884 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
4885 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
4886 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
4887 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
4888 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
4889 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
4890 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
4891 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
4892 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
4893 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
4894 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
4895 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
4896 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
4897 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
4898 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
4899 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
4901 struct wireless_dev {
4902 struct wiphy *wiphy;
4903 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4905 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
4906 struct list_head list;
4907 struct net_device *netdev;
4909 u32 identifier;
4911 struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
4912 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
4914 struct mutex mtx;
4916 bool use_4addr, is_running;
4918 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
4920 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
4921 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
4922 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
4923 struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
4924 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
4925 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
4926 u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
4928 struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
4929 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
4931 struct list_head event_list;
4932 spinlock_t event_lock;
4934 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
4935 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
4936 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4938 bool ibss_fixed;
4939 bool ibss_dfs_possible;
4941 bool ps;
4942 int ps_timeout;
4944 int beacon_interval;
4946 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
4948 u32 owner_nlportid;
4949 bool nl_owner_dead;
4951 bool cac_started;
4952 unsigned long cac_start_time;
4953 unsigned int cac_time_ms;
4955 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
4956 /* wext data */
4957 struct {
4958 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
4959 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
4960 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
4961 const u8 *ie;
4962 size_t ie_len;
4963 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
4964 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
4965 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
4966 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
4967 bool prev_bssid_valid;
4968 } wext;
4969 #endif
4971 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
4973 struct list_head pmsr_list;
4974 spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
4975 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
4978 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
4980 if (wdev->netdev)
4981 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
4982 return wdev->address;
4985 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
4987 if (wdev->netdev)
4988 return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
4989 return wdev->is_running;
4993 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
4995 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
4996 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
4998 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5000 BUG_ON(!wdev);
5001 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5005 * DOC: Utility functions
5007 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5011 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5012 * @chan: channel number
5013 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5014 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5016 int ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5019 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5020 * @freq: center frequency
5021 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5023 int ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq);
5026 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5028 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5029 * @freq: the center frequency of the channel
5031 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5033 struct ieee80211_channel *ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq);
5036 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5038 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5039 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5040 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5042 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5043 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5044 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5045 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5047 struct ieee80211_rate *
5048 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5049 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5052 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5053 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5054 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5056 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5057 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5059 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5060 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5063 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5065 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5066 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.txt
5069 struct radiotap_align_size {
5070 uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5073 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5074 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5075 int n_bits;
5076 uint32_t oui;
5077 uint8_t subns;
5080 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5081 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5082 int n_ns;
5086 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5087 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5088 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5089 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5090 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5091 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5092 * the beginning of the actual data portion
5093 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5094 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5095 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5096 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5097 * radiotap namespace or not
5099 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5100 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5101 * @_arg_index: next argument index
5102 * @_arg: next argument pointer
5103 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5104 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5105 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5106 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5107 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5108 * next bitmap word
5110 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5111 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5114 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5115 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5116 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5117 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5119 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5120 __le32 *_next_bitmap;
5122 unsigned char *this_arg;
5123 int this_arg_index;
5124 int this_arg_size;
5126 int is_radiotap_ns;
5128 int _max_length;
5129 int _arg_index;
5130 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5131 int _reset_on_ext;
5135 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5136 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5137 int max_length,
5138 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5141 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5144 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5145 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5148 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5150 * @skb: the frame
5152 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5153 * returns the 802.11 header length.
5155 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5156 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5157 * 802.11 header.
5159 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5162 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5163 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5164 * Return: The header length in bytes.
5166 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5169 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5170 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5171 * (first byte) will be accessed
5172 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5173 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5175 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5178 * DOC: Data path helpers
5180 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5181 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5182 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5186 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5187 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5188 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5189 * of it being pushed into the SKB
5190 * @addr: the device MAC address
5191 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5192 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5193 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5195 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5196 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5197 u8 data_offset);
5200 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5201 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5202 * @addr: the device MAC address
5203 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5204 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5206 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5207 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5209 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0);
5213 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5215 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5216 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5217 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5219 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5220 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5221 * initialized by by the caller.
5222 * @addr: The device MAC address.
5223 * @iftype: The device interface type.
5224 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5225 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5226 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5228 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5229 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5230 const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5231 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5234 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5235 * @skb: the data frame
5236 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5237 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5239 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5240 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5243 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5245 * @eid: element ID
5246 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5247 * @len: length of data
5248 * @match: byte array to match
5249 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5250 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5251 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5252 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5253 * the data portion instead.
5255 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5256 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5257 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5258 * requested element struct.
5260 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5261 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5262 * byte array to match.
5264 const struct element *
5265 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5266 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5267 unsigned int match_offset);
5270 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5272 * @eid: element ID
5273 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5274 * @len: length of data
5275 * @match: byte array to match
5276 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5277 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5278 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5279 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5280 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5281 * the second byte is the IE length.
5283 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5284 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5285 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5286 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5287 * element ID.
5289 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5290 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5291 * byte array to match.
5293 static inline const u8 *
5294 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5295 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5296 unsigned int match_offset)
5298 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5299 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5301 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5302 (!match_len && match_offset)))
5303 return NULL;
5305 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5306 match, match_len,
5307 match_offset ?
5308 match_offset - 2 : 0);
5312 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5314 * @eid: element ID
5315 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5316 * @len: length of data
5318 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5319 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5320 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5321 * requested element struct.
5323 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5324 * having to fit into the given data.
5326 static inline const struct element *
5327 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5329 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5333 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5335 * @eid: element ID
5336 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5337 * @len: length of data
5339 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5340 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5341 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5342 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5344 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5345 * having to fit into the given data.
5347 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5349 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5353 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5355 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5356 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5357 * @len: length of data
5359 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5360 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5361 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5362 * requested element struct.
5364 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5365 * having to fit into the given data.
5367 static inline const struct element *
5368 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5370 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5371 &ext_eid, 1, 0);
5375 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5377 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5378 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5379 * @len: length of data
5381 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5382 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5383 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5384 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5386 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5387 * having to fit into the given data.
5389 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5391 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5392 &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5396 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5398 * @oui: vendor OUI
5399 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5400 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5401 * @len: length of data
5403 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5404 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5405 * return the element structure for the requested element.
5407 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5408 * the given data.
5410 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5411 const u8 *ies,
5412 unsigned int len);
5415 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5417 * @oui: vendor OUI
5418 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5419 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5420 * @len: length of data
5422 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5423 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
5424 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5425 * element ID.
5427 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5428 * the given data.
5430 static inline const u8 *
5431 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5432 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
5434 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
5438 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
5440 * @dev: network device
5441 * @addr: STA MAC address
5443 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
5444 * devices upon STA association.
5446 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
5449 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
5451 * TODO
5455 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
5456 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
5457 * conflicts)
5458 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
5459 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
5460 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
5461 * alpha2.
5463 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
5464 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
5465 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
5466 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
5467 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
5468 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
5470 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
5471 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
5472 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
5474 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5475 * an -ENOMEM.
5477 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
5479 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
5482 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
5483 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5484 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
5486 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
5487 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
5488 * information.
5490 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5492 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5493 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5496 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers
5497 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5498 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
5500 * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain
5501 * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see
5502 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
5504 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5506 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5507 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5510 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
5511 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5512 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
5514 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
5515 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
5516 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
5517 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
5518 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
5519 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
5520 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
5521 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
5522 * that called this helper.
5524 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5525 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
5528 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
5529 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
5530 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
5532 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
5533 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
5534 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
5535 * and processed already.
5537 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
5538 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
5539 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
5540 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
5541 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
5542 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
5543 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
5545 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5546 u32 center_freq);
5549 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
5550 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
5552 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
5553 * proper string representation.
5555 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
5558 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
5559 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
5561 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
5563 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5566 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
5571 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
5572 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
5574 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
5575 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
5576 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
5578 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query
5579 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
5580 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
5582 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5583 * an -ENODATA.
5585 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
5587 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
5588 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
5591 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
5592 * functions and BSS handling helpers
5596 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
5598 * @request: the corresponding scan request
5599 * @info: information about the completed scan
5601 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
5602 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5605 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
5607 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
5608 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
5610 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
5613 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
5615 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
5616 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
5618 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
5619 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
5620 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
5622 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
5625 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
5627 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
5628 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
5630 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
5631 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
5632 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
5633 * This function should be called with rtnl locked.
5635 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
5638 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
5639 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
5640 * @data: the BSS metadata
5641 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
5642 * @len: length of the management frame
5643 * @gfp: context flags
5645 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
5646 * the BSS should be updated/added.
5648 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
5649 * Or %NULL on error.
5651 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5652 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5653 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
5654 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
5655 gfp_t gfp);
5657 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5658 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5659 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
5660 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
5661 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
5662 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
5664 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
5665 .chan = rx_channel,
5666 .scan_width = scan_width,
5667 .signal = signal,
5670 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
5673 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5674 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5675 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
5676 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
5677 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
5679 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
5680 .chan = rx_channel,
5681 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5682 .signal = signal,
5685 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
5689 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
5690 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
5691 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
5692 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
5693 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
5695 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
5696 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
5698 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
5699 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
5700 u64 new_bssid_u64;
5702 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
5704 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
5706 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
5710 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
5711 * @element: element to check
5712 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
5714 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
5715 const struct element *non_inherit_element);
5718 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
5719 * @ie: ies
5720 * @ielen: length of IEs
5721 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
5722 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
5723 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
5724 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
5726 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
5727 const struct element *mbssid_elem,
5728 const struct element *sub_elem,
5729 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
5732 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
5733 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
5734 * from a beacon or probe response
5735 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
5736 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
5738 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
5739 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
5740 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
5741 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
5745 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
5747 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
5748 * @data: the BSS metadata
5749 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
5750 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
5751 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
5752 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
5753 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
5754 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
5755 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
5756 * @gfp: context flags
5758 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
5759 * the BSS should be updated/added.
5761 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
5762 * Or %NULL on error.
5764 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5765 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5766 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
5767 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
5768 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
5769 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
5770 gfp_t gfp);
5772 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5773 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5774 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
5775 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
5776 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
5777 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
5778 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
5779 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
5781 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
5782 .chan = rx_channel,
5783 .scan_width = scan_width,
5784 .signal = signal,
5787 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
5788 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
5789 gfp);
5792 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
5793 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5794 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
5795 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
5796 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
5797 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
5798 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
5800 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
5801 .chan = rx_channel,
5802 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5803 .signal = signal,
5806 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
5807 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
5808 gfp);
5812 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
5813 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
5814 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
5815 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
5816 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
5817 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
5818 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
5819 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
5821 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5822 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
5823 const u8 *bssid,
5824 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5825 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
5826 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
5827 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
5828 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5829 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
5830 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
5832 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
5833 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
5834 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
5838 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
5839 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
5840 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
5842 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
5844 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
5847 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
5848 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
5849 * @bss: the BSS struct
5851 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
5853 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
5856 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
5857 * @wiphy: the wiphy
5858 * @bss: the bss to remove
5860 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
5861 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
5862 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
5863 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
5865 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
5868 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
5870 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
5871 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
5872 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
5874 * @wiphy: the wiphy
5875 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
5876 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
5877 * @iter: the iterator function to call
5878 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
5880 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5881 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5882 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5883 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
5884 void *data),
5885 void *iter_data);
5887 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
5888 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
5890 switch (chandef->width) {
5891 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
5892 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
5893 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
5894 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
5895 default:
5896 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
5901 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
5902 * @dev: network device
5903 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
5904 * @len: length of the frame data
5906 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
5907 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
5908 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
5909 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
5910 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
5911 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
5912 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
5913 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
5914 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
5915 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
5917 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
5919 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
5922 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
5923 * @dev: network device
5924 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
5926 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
5927 * mutex.
5929 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
5932 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
5933 * @dev: network device
5934 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
5935 * moves to cfg80211 in this call
5936 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
5937 * @len: length of the frame data
5938 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
5939 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
5940 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
5941 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
5943 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
5944 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
5946 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
5948 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
5949 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
5950 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
5951 int uapsd_queues,
5952 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
5955 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
5956 * @dev: network device
5957 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
5959 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
5961 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
5964 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
5965 * @dev: network device
5966 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
5968 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
5969 * an association attempt was abandoned.
5970 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
5972 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
5975 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
5976 * @dev: network device
5977 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
5978 * @len: length of the frame data
5980 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
5981 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
5982 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
5983 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
5985 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
5988 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
5989 * @dev: network device
5990 * @buf: deauthentication frame (header + body)
5991 * @len: length of the frame data
5993 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
5994 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
5995 * frame was not protected. This function may sleep.
5997 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
5998 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6001 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6002 * @dev: network device
6003 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6004 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6005 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6006 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6007 * @gfp: allocation flags
6009 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6010 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6011 * primitive.
6013 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6014 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6015 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6018 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6020 * @dev: network device
6021 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6022 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6023 * @gfp: allocation flags
6025 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6026 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6027 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6028 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6029 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6030 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6032 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6033 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6036 * cfg80211_notify_new_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer candidate
6038 * @dev: network device
6039 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6040 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6041 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6042 * @gfp: allocation flags
6044 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6045 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6046 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6048 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6049 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6050 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6053 * DOC: RFkill integration
6055 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6056 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6057 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6058 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6059 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6061 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6062 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6063 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6067 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6068 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6069 * @blocked: block status
6071 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked);
6074 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6075 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6077 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6080 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6081 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6083 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6086 * DOC: Vendor commands
6088 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6089 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6090 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6091 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6092 * the configuration mechanism.
6094 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6095 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6096 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6098 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6099 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6100 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6101 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6102 * managers etc. need.
6105 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6106 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6107 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6108 int approxlen);
6110 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6111 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6112 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6113 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6114 unsigned int portid,
6115 int vendor_event_idx,
6116 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6118 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6121 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6122 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6123 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6124 * be put into the skb
6126 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6127 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6128 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6130 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6131 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6132 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6133 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6134 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6135 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6136 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6138 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6139 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6141 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6143 static inline struct sk_buff *
6144 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6146 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6147 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6151 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6152 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6153 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6155 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6156 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6157 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the
6158 * skb regardless of the return value.
6160 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6162 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6165 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender
6166 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6168 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6169 * Valid to call only there.
6171 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6174 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6175 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6176 * @wdev: the wireless device
6177 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6178 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6179 * be put into the skb
6180 * @gfp: allocation flags
6182 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6183 * vendor-specific multicast group.
6185 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6186 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6187 * attribute.
6189 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6190 * skb to send the event.
6192 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6194 static inline struct sk_buff *
6195 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6196 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6198 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6199 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6200 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6204 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6205 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6206 * @wdev: the wireless device
6207 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6208 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6209 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6210 * be put into the skb
6211 * @gfp: allocation flags
6213 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6214 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6215 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6216 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6218 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6219 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6220 * attribute.
6222 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6223 * skb to send the event.
6225 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6227 static inline struct sk_buff *
6228 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6229 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6230 unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6231 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6233 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6234 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6235 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6239 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6240 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6241 * @gfp: allocation flags
6243 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6244 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6246 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6248 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6251 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6253 * DOC: Test mode
6255 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6256 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6257 * factory programming.
6259 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6260 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6264 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6265 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6266 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6267 * be put into the skb
6269 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6270 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6271 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6273 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6274 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6275 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6276 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6277 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6278 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6279 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6281 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6282 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6284 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6286 static inline struct sk_buff *
6287 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6289 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6290 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6294 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6295 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6296 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6298 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6299 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6300 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb
6301 * regardless of the return value.
6303 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6305 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6307 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6311 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6312 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6313 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6314 * be put into the skb
6315 * @gfp: allocation flags
6317 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6318 * testmode multicast group.
6320 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6321 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6322 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6323 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6324 * in any other way.
6326 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6327 * skb to send the event.
6329 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6331 static inline struct sk_buff *
6332 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6334 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6335 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6336 approxlen, gfp);
6340 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6341 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6342 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6343 * @gfp: allocation flags
6345 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6346 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6347 * consumes it.
6349 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6351 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6354 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6355 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd),
6356 #else
6357 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6358 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6359 #endif
6362 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6363 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6364 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6365 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6366 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6367 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6368 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6369 * status for a FILS connection.
6370 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6371 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6372 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6373 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6375 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6376 const u8 *kek;
6377 size_t kek_len;
6378 bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6379 u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6380 const u8 *pmk;
6381 size_t pmk_len;
6382 const u8 *pmkid;
6386 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6387 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6388 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6389 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6390 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6391 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6392 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6393 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6394 * case.
6395 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6396 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6397 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6398 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6399 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6400 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6401 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6402 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6403 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
6404 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6405 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
6406 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
6407 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6408 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6409 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6410 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6411 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6412 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6414 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
6415 int status;
6416 const u8 *bssid;
6417 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6418 const u8 *req_ie;
6419 size_t req_ie_len;
6420 const u8 *resp_ie;
6421 size_t resp_ie_len;
6422 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6423 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
6427 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6429 * @dev: network device
6430 * @params: connection response parameters
6431 * @gfp: allocation flags
6433 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6434 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6435 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
6436 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
6437 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
6438 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6440 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
6441 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
6442 gfp_t gfp);
6445 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6447 * @dev: network device
6448 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6449 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6450 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6451 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6452 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6453 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6454 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6455 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6456 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6457 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6458 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6459 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6460 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6461 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6462 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6463 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6464 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6465 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6466 * case.
6467 * @gfp: allocation flags
6468 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6469 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6470 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6471 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6472 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6473 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6475 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6476 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6477 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
6478 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
6479 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6480 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6482 static inline void
6483 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6484 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
6485 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
6486 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
6487 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6489 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
6491 memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
6492 params.status = status;
6493 params.bssid = bssid;
6494 params.bss = bss;
6495 params.req_ie = req_ie;
6496 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
6497 params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
6498 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
6499 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
6501 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
6505 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6507 * @dev: network device
6508 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6509 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6510 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6511 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6512 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6513 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6514 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6515 * the real status code for failures.
6516 * @gfp: allocation flags
6518 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6519 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6520 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
6521 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6522 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6524 static inline void
6525 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6526 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
6527 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
6528 u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
6530 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
6531 resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
6532 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
6536 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
6538 * @dev: network device
6539 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6540 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6541 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6542 * @gfp: allocation flags
6543 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
6545 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
6546 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
6547 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
6548 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
6549 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
6550 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6551 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6553 static inline void
6554 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6555 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
6556 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6558 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
6559 gfp, timeout_reason);
6563 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
6565 * @channel: the channel of the new AP
6566 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
6567 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
6568 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6569 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6570 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6571 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6572 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
6574 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
6575 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
6576 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6577 const u8 *bssid;
6578 const u8 *req_ie;
6579 size_t req_ie_len;
6580 const u8 *resp_ie;
6581 size_t resp_ie_len;
6582 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6586 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
6588 * @dev: network device
6589 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
6590 * @gfp: allocation flags
6592 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
6593 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
6594 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
6595 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
6596 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
6597 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
6598 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
6599 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
6600 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
6601 * released while diconneting from the current bss.
6603 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
6604 gfp_t gfp);
6607 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
6609 * @dev: network device
6610 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6611 * @gfp: allocation flags
6613 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
6614 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
6615 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
6616 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
6617 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
6618 * indicate the 802.11 association.
6620 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6621 gfp_t gfp);
6624 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
6626 * @dev: network device
6627 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
6628 * @ie_len: length of IEs
6629 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
6630 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
6631 * @gfp: allocation flags
6633 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
6634 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
6636 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
6637 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
6638 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
6641 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
6642 * @wdev: wireless device
6643 * @cookie: the request cookie
6644 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
6645 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
6646 * channel
6647 * @gfp: allocation flags
6649 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
6650 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
6651 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
6654 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6655 * @wdev: wireless device
6656 * @cookie: the request cookie
6657 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
6658 * @gfp: allocation flags
6660 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
6661 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
6662 gfp_t gfp);
6665 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
6666 * @wdev: wireless device
6667 * @cookie: the requested cookie
6668 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
6669 * @gfp: allocation flags
6671 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
6672 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
6675 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
6677 * @sinfo: the station information
6678 * @gfp: allocation flags
6680 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
6683 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
6684 * @sinfo: the station information
6686 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
6687 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
6688 * the stack.)
6690 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
6692 kfree(sinfo->pertid);
6696 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
6698 * @dev: the netdev
6699 * @mac_addr: the station's address
6700 * @sinfo: the station information
6701 * @gfp: allocation flags
6703 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
6704 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
6707 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
6708 * @dev: the netdev
6709 * @mac_addr: the station's address
6710 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
6711 * @gfp: allocation flags
6713 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
6714 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
6717 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
6719 * @dev: the netdev
6720 * @mac_addr: the station's address
6721 * @gfp: allocation flags
6723 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
6724 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
6726 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
6730 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
6732 * @dev: the netdev
6733 * @mac_addr: the station's address
6734 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
6735 * @gfp: allocation flags
6737 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
6738 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
6739 * for some reasons, this function is called.
6741 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
6742 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
6744 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
6745 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
6746 gfp_t gfp);
6749 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
6750 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
6751 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
6752 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
6753 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
6754 * @len: length of the frame data
6755 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
6757 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
6758 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
6760 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
6761 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
6762 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
6763 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
6765 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
6766 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
6769 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
6770 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
6771 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
6772 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
6773 * @len: length of the frame data
6774 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
6775 * @gfp: context flags
6777 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
6778 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
6779 * transmission attempt.
6781 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
6782 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
6786 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
6787 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
6788 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf
6789 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear.
6790 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
6791 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that
6792 * skb->protocol is set appropriately.
6793 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
6795 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
6796 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
6797 * control port frames over nl80211.
6799 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
6800 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
6802 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
6804 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
6805 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
6808 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
6809 * @dev: network device
6810 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
6811 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6812 * @gfp: context flags
6814 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
6815 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
6817 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
6818 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6819 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
6822 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
6823 * @dev: network device
6824 * @peer: peer's MAC address
6825 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
6826 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
6827 * threshold (to account for temporary interference)
6828 * @gfp: context flags
6830 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
6831 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
6834 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
6835 * @dev: network device
6836 * @peer: peer's MAC address
6837 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
6838 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
6839 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
6840 * @gfp: context flags
6842 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
6843 * given interval is exceeded.
6845 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
6846 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
6849 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
6850 * @dev: network device
6851 * @gfp: context flags
6853 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
6855 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
6858 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
6859 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6860 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
6861 * @gfp: context flags
6863 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
6865 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6866 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
6869 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
6870 * @dev: network device
6871 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
6872 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
6873 * @gfp: context flags
6875 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
6876 * frame.
6878 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
6879 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
6880 gfp_t gfp);
6883 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
6884 * @netdev: network device
6885 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
6886 * @event: type of event
6887 * @gfp: context flags
6889 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
6890 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
6891 * also by full-MAC drivers.
6893 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
6894 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6895 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
6899 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
6900 * @dev: network device
6901 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
6902 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
6903 * @gfp: allocation flags
6905 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6906 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6909 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
6910 * @dev: network device
6911 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
6912 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
6913 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
6914 * @gfp: allocation flags
6916 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
6917 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
6920 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
6921 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
6922 * @addr: the transmitter address
6923 * @gfp: context flags
6925 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
6926 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
6927 * sender.
6928 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
6929 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
6931 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
6932 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
6935 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
6936 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
6937 * @addr: the transmitter address
6938 * @gfp: context flags
6940 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
6941 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
6942 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
6943 * station to avoid event flooding.
6944 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
6945 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
6947 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
6948 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
6951 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
6952 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
6953 * @addr: the address of the peer
6954 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
6955 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
6956 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
6957 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
6958 * @gfp: allocation flags
6960 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6961 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
6962 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
6965 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
6966 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
6967 * @frame: the frame
6968 * @len: length of the frame
6969 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
6970 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
6972 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
6973 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
6974 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
6976 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6977 const u8 *frame, size_t len,
6978 int freq, int sig_dbm);
6981 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
6982 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6983 * @chandef: the channel definition
6984 * @iftype: interface type
6986 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
6987 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
6989 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6990 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6991 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
6994 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
6995 * @wiphy: the wiphy
6996 * @chandef: the channel definition
6997 * @iftype: interface type
6999 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7000 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7001 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7002 * more permissive conditions.
7004 * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7006 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7007 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7008 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7011 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7012 * @dev: the device which switched channels
7013 * @chandef: the new channel definition
7015 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7016 * driver context!
7018 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7019 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7022 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7023 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7024 * @chandef: the future channel definition
7025 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7027 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7028 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7029 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7031 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7032 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7033 u8 count);
7036 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7038 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7039 * @band: band pointer to fill
7041 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7043 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7044 enum nl80211_band *band);
7047 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7049 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7050 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7052 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7054 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7055 u8 *op_class);
7058 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7059 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7060 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7061 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7062 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7063 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7064 * @gfp: allocation flags
7066 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7067 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7068 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7069 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7070 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7072 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7073 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7074 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7077 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7078 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7080 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7082 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7085 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7086 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7088 * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned,
7089 * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that
7090 * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function
7091 * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by
7092 * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also
7093 * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g.
7094 * when the device is unbound from the driver.
7096 * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7098 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7101 * struct cfg80211_ft_event - FT Information Elements
7102 * @ies: FT IEs
7103 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7104 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7105 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7106 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7108 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7109 const u8 *ies;
7110 size_t ies_len;
7111 const u8 *target_ap;
7112 const u8 *ric_ies;
7113 size_t ric_ies_len;
7117 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7118 * @netdev: network device
7119 * @ft_event: IE information
7121 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7122 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7125 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7126 * @ies: the input IE buffer
7127 * @len: the input length
7128 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7129 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7130 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7131 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7133 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7134 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7136 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7137 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7138 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7140 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7141 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7142 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7145 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7146 * @ies: the IE buffer
7147 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7148 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7149 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7150 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7151 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7152 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7153 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7154 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7156 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7157 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7158 * split.
7160 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7161 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7163 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7164 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7165 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7167 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7168 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7169 * of the buffer should be used.
7171 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7172 const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7173 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7174 size_t offset);
7177 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7178 * @ies: the IE buffer
7179 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7180 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7181 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7182 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7183 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7184 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7186 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7187 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7188 * split.
7190 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7191 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7193 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7194 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7195 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7197 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7198 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7199 * of the buffer should be used.
7201 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7202 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7204 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7208 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7209 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7210 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7211 * @gfp: allocation flags
7213 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7214 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7215 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7216 * else caused the wakeup.
7218 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7219 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7220 gfp_t gfp);
7223 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7225 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7226 * @gfp: allocation flags
7228 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7229 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7230 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7232 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7235 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7236 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7238 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7240 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7243 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7245 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7246 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7248 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7249 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7250 * the interface combinations.
7252 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7253 struct iface_combination_params *params);
7256 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7258 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7259 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7260 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7261 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7263 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7264 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7265 * purposes.
7267 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7268 struct iface_combination_params *params,
7269 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7270 void *data),
7271 void *data);
7274 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7276 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7277 * @wdev: wireless device
7278 * @gfp: context flags
7280 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7281 * disconnected.
7283 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7285 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7286 gfp_t gfp);
7289 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7290 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7292 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7293 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7294 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7295 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7297 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7298 * the driver while the function is running.
7300 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7303 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
7305 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7306 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7308 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7309 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7311 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7312 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7314 u8 *ft_byte;
7316 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7317 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
7321 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
7323 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7324 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7326 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7327 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7329 static inline bool
7330 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7331 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7333 u8 ft_byte;
7335 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7336 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
7340 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
7341 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
7343 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
7345 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
7348 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
7349 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
7350 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
7351 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
7352 * result.
7353 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
7354 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7355 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
7356 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
7357 * @info_len: the length of the &info
7358 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
7359 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
7361 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
7362 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
7363 u8 inst_id;
7364 u8 peer_inst_id;
7365 const u8 *addr;
7366 u8 info_len;
7367 const u8 *info;
7368 u64 cookie;
7372 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
7373 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7374 * @match: match notification parameters
7375 * @gfp: allocation flags
7377 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
7378 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
7379 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
7381 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7382 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
7385 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7387 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7388 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7389 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7390 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
7391 * @gfp: allocation flags
7393 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
7395 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7396 u8 inst_id,
7397 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7398 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
7400 /* ethtool helper */
7401 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
7404 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
7405 * @netdev: network device
7406 * @params: External authentication parameters
7407 * @gfp: allocation flags
7408 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
7410 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
7411 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
7412 gfp_t gfp);
7415 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
7416 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7417 * @req: the original measurement request
7418 * @result: the result data
7419 * @gfp: allocation flags
7421 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7422 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7423 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
7424 gfp_t gfp);
7427 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
7428 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7429 * @req: the original measurement request
7430 * @gfp: allocation flags
7432 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
7433 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
7435 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7436 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7437 gfp_t gfp);
7440 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
7441 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7442 * @iftype: interface type
7443 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
7444 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
7446 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
7447 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
7448 * check_swif is '1'.
7450 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
7451 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
7454 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
7456 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
7458 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \
7459 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7460 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \
7461 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7462 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \
7463 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7464 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \
7465 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7466 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \
7467 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7468 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \
7469 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7470 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \
7471 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7472 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \
7473 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7475 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
7476 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7477 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
7478 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7480 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \
7481 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
7483 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
7484 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7486 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
7487 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg
7488 #else
7489 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
7490 ({ \
7491 if (0) \
7492 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \
7493 0; \
7495 #endif
7498 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
7499 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
7500 * file/line information and a backtrace.
7502 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \
7503 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
7506 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
7507 * @netdev: network device
7508 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
7509 * @gfp: allocation flags
7511 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7512 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
7513 gfp_t gfp);
7515 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */